annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 3566:ce7bd50bafa7 v7.3.543

updated for version 7.3.543 Problem: The cursor is in the wrong line after using ":copen". (John Beckett) Solution: Invoke more drastic redraw method.
author Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
date Wed, 06 Jun 2012 16:29:10 +0200
parents 9cb3a75a20b9
children b9aa7fb4a928
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
3513
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 May 16
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Options *options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 1. Setting options |set-option|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 3. Options summary |option-summary|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 number has a numeric value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 string has a string value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 ==============================================================================
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 *:se* *:set*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 *E518* *E519*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 Number option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 String option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
43 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 :se[t] {option}! or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
54 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 :se[t] {option}={value} or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 :se[t] {option}:{value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 Set string or number option to {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63 (hex and octal are only available for machines which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 have the strtol() function).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72 backslashes in {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
80 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
81 present the option value doesn't change.
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
82 Also see |:set-args| above.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
87 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
92
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
95 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
96 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
97 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 becomes empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
100 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 one by one to avoid problems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
107 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109 and the following arguments will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111 *:set-verbose*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
113 was last set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
115 < shiftwidth=4 ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
116 Last set from modeline ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
117 cindent ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
118 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
119 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
120 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
121 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125 'compatible'.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
126 A few special texts:
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
127 Last set from modeline ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
128 Option was set in a |modeline|.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
129 Last set from --cmd argument ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
130 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
131 Last set from -c argument ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
132 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
133 |-q|.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
134 Last set from environment variable ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
135 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
136 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
137 Last set from error handler ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
138 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
139
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
140 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142 *:set-termcap* *E522*
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
143 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 :set <M-b>=^[b
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152
2726
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
153 You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
154 :set t_xy=^[foo;
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
155 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
156 codes as you like: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
157 :map <t_xy> something
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
158 < *E846*
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
159 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
160 value will result in an error: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
161 :set t_kb=
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
162 :set t_kb
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
163 E846: Key code not set: t_kb
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
164
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
165 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
166 security reasons.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
167
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
169 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 |more-prompt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173 *option-backslash*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 down).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 A few examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
183 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
184 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 :set titlestring=hi\|there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189
642
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
190 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
191 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
192 option to 'hi "there"': >
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
193 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
194
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
195 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 etc.) is used like explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
206 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 :set guioptions+=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 Remove a flag from an option like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215 :set guioptions-=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
217 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 doesn't appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
222 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228 :set term=$TERM.new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 Handling of local options *local-options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 expects is a bit complicated...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 the buffer was edited last are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 :set list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271 command you have also set the global value. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 :set nolist
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 :setlocal list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
278 global value. Note that if you do this next: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
279 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
280 You will not get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
281 "one". The options local to a window are not remembered for each buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 *:setl* *:setlocal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 local value. If the option does not have a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 value the global value is set.
2413
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
288 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
289 local options.
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
290 Without argument: Display local values for all local
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
291 options which are different from the default.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 When displaying a specific local option, show the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
293 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
294 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
295 before the option name.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
296 For a global option the global value is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297 shown (but that might change in the future).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
300 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
301 copying the value.
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
302 {not in Vi}
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
303
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
304 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
305 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 *:setg* *:setglobal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 option without changing the local value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
2413
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
312 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
313 local options.
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
314 Without argument: display global values for all local
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
315 options which are different from the default.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 For buffer-local and window-local options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 Command global value local value ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 :set option=value set set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 :setlocal option=value - set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 :setglobal option=value set -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 :set option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 :setlocal option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 :setglobal option? display -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 Global options with a local value *global-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
330 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
331 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
332 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
333 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
334 value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 :set makeprg=gmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
342 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
343 files. You use this command: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 :setlocal makeprg=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 "<" flag, like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 :setlocal autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
352 when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
353 :set path<
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
354 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
355 used. Thus it does the same as: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
356 :setlocal path=
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 Setting the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 This is short for: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 :if !did_filetype()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
375 *option-window* *optwin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 Options are grouped by function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 short help to open a help window with more help for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 window, in which case the window below help window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 used (skipping the option-window).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 |+autocmd| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391 *$HOME*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393 option and after a space or comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396 of user "user". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
403 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
404 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
405
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413 *:fix* *:fixdel*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416 CTRL-? CTRL-H
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
420
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424 :fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425 < This works no matter what the actual code for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 backspace is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429 use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432 : fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
435 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
444 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
445 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447 *Linux-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 putting this line in your rc.local: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453 *NetBSD-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455 the right code, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458 keysym 22 = BackSpace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459 < You need to restart for this to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
461 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
462 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465 to set options automatically for one or more files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 |:mksession|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 many other things. See |autocommand|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
475 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
476 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
477 modelines. This is explained here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
478
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
480 There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
481 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
483 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
484 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
485 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
486 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
487 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space or ':',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
488 where each part between ':' is the argument for a ":set"
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
489 command (can be empty)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
490
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
491 Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
492 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
494 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
495
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
496 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
498 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
499 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
500 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
501 [white] optional white space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
502 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
503 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
504 argument for a ":set" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
505 : a colon
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
506 [text] any text or empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
507
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
508 Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
509 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
510
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
511 The white space before {vi:|vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the chance
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
512 that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: "vi:" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513 "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
514 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this could be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
515 short for "example:").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
517 *modeline-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
518 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
519 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
520 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
521 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
522 depends on which one was opened last.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
523
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
524 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
525 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
526 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
527 in another window. But window-local options will be set.
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
528
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
529 *modeline-version*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
530 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
531 number can be specified where "vim:" is used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534 vim={vers}: version {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 {vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
537 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
538 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
539 To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
540 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
541 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
542
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
543
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
544 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
545 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
547 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
548 like:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
549 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
550 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
551 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
553 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
554
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
555 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
556 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
557 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
558 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
559 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
562 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
563 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
564 |sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
565 causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
566 are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text.
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
567 The mail ftplugin does this, for example.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
569 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
570 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
571 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
572 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574 "VAR".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577 3. Options summary *option-summary*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
578
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
579 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
580 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
582 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
583 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
586 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
587 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
588
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
590 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
593 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
596 program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 global one option for all buffers and windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
599 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
600 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
601
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
602 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
603 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
605 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
606 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
607 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
608 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
610 buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
611
519
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
612 Hidden options *hidden-options*
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
613
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
614 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
615 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
616 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
617 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
618 option though, it is not stored.
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
619
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
620 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
621 if exists('&foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
622 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
623 supported use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
624 if exists('+foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
625 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
626 *E355*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
627 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
628
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
629 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
630 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
631 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
632 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
633 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
635 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
637 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
638 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
639 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
640 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
641
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
642 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
643 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
644 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
645 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
647 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
648 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
649 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
650 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
651 'revins'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
652 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
653
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
654 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
655 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
656 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
657 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
658 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
659 feature}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
660 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
661 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
662
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
663 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
664 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
665 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
666 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
668 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
669 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
670 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
671 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
672 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
673 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
674 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
675 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
676 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
677 letters, Cyrillic letters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
679 There are currently two possible values:
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
680 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
681 expected by most users.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
682 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
2492
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
683 *E834* *E835*
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
684 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
685 contains a character that would be double width.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
686
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
687 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
688 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
689 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
690 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
691 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
692 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
693 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
694 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
695 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
696 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
697 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
698 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
699 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
700 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
701
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
702 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
703 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
704 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
705 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
706 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
707 on Mac OS X}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
708 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
709 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
710 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
711 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712 to its default (empty string).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
713
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
715 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
716 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
717 {not in Vi}
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
718 {only available when compiled with it, use
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
719 exists("+autochdir") to check}
438
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
720 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
721 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
722 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
723 or selected.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
724 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
725 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
726 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
727
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
728 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
729 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
731 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
734 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 Setting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
736 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
738 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
739 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
740 - Set the 'delcombine' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
741 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 Resetting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
747 option).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748 Also see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
749
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
752 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
759 take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
760 one which encompasses:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
763 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
764 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
765 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
766 form.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
770 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
776 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
777 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
778 in 'cpoptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
779 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
780 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
781 line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 a different way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
794 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 using the global value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 :set autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
864
bc620d6bdf06 updated for version 7.0g03
vimboss
parents: 859
diff changeset
805 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
806 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
807 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
808 'autowriteall' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
810 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
811 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
812 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
814 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817 been set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
819 *'background'* *'bg'*
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
820 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
825 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 This will not always be correct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830 color, see |:hi-normal|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
833 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
834 change. *g:colors_name*
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
835 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
838 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
839 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
840
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
841 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
842 :set background&
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
843 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
844 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
850 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
851 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
853 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
854
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
855 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark".
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
856 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
857 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
858 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
859
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
860 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
861 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
862 :if &term == "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
863 : set background=dark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
864 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 the setting of the 'background' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871 done with ":syntax on".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
873 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879 a way to backspace over something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 stop once at the start of insert.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
888 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
889 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
890 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
891 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
904 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
905 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
906 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
907 |backup-table| for more explanations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
908 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910 oldest version of a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
911 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
916 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
918 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
920 The main values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922 "no" rename the file and write a new one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
934 not of the real file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
935
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
936 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937 + It's fast.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
940 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
944 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
945 copy will be made.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
947 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
949 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
950 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
951 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
952 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
953 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954 be propagated back to the original source.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
955 *crontab*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
959 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
964 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
965 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
966 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
967 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
968 others.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
969
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
970 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
971 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
972 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
973 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
974 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
975 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
976 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 again not rename the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
978
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
981 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
982 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
984 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
985 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
986 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
987 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
988 create it for you.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
989 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
990 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
991 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
992 as the edited file.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
993 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
994 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
995 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
996 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
997 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
998 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1000 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1001 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1002 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1003 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1004 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1005 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1006 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1007 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1008 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1009 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1010 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1011 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1012 home directory for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1013 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1014 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1015 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1016 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1017 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1019 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1020 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1021 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1022 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1023 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1024 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1025 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1026 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1027 ".bak" that you want to keep.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1028 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1029
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1030 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1031 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1032 include a timestamp. >
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1033 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1034 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1035
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1036 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1037 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1038 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1039 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1040 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1044 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1045 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1047 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1048 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1049
3513
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1050 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1051 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1052 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1053 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1054
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1055 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1056 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1057 :let backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1058
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1059 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1060 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1061 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1062
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1063 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1064 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1065 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1076 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1079 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1080 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
790
c8680debe1cc updated for version 7.0230
vimboss
parents: 782
diff changeset
1081 global or local to buffer |global-local|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1082 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1083 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1084 feature}
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1085 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1086 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1087
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1088 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1089 v:beval_winnr number of the window
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1090 v:beval_lnum line number
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1091 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1092 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1093
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1094 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1095 Example: >
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1096 function! MyBalloonExpr()
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1097 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1098 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1099 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1100 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1101 endfunction
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1102 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1103 set ballooneval
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1104 <
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1105 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1106 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1107 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1108 or Sun Workshop).
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1109
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1110 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1111 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1112
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1113 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1114 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1115
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1116 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1117 if has("balloon_multiline")
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1118 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1119 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1120 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1121
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1122 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1123 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1124 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1125 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1126 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129 'textwidth' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1131 'modeline' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1132 'expandtab' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1133 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1134 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1135 separates lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1136 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1137 file is read without conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1139 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 saved option values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1145 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147 files you edit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1151 the 'endofline' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1155 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1157 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1158 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1160 Also see |'conskey'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1161
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1162 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1163 'bomb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1165 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1169 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 - this option is on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171 - the 'binary' option is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 endian variants.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1177 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1182 will be restored when writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1188 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1189 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1190 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1191 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1192 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1194 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
29
ac33b7c03fac updated for version 7.0018
vimboss
parents: 26
diff changeset
1195 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1196 global
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1197 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1198 Win32 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1199 Which directory to use for the file browser:
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1200 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
1201 file was opened or saved.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203 current Use the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1204 {path} Use the specified directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1205
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1206 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1207 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1208 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1209 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1212 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 displayed in a window:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 is not set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218 |:hide|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221 |:bdelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224 |:bwipeout|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1225
82
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1226 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
1227 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
1228 that switch between buffers temporarily.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1229 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1232 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1234 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1235 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1240 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 <empty> normal buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251 written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1252 nowrite buffer which will not be written
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1253 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
1254 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1255 |+autocmd| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1257 or list of locations |:lwindow|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1258 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 manually)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1264 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1265
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1266 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1267 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1268 you are not supposed to change it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1270 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 work (":w filename" does work though).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 example when you quit Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 command.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1282 *E676*
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1283 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1284 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1285 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1286 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1287 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1290 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292 {not in Vi}
804
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1293 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1294 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 these words, separated by a comma:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
493
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1299 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1300 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1301 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1302 functions are used when available.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1303 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1304 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1305 This probably only matters for Turkish.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
1315 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./"
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
1316 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1319 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1320 in the current directory first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1321 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1323 override it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1326 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329 *'cedit'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1340 :set cedit=<C-Y>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1341 :set cedit=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1342 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 See |cmdwin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1349 and |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1352 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 different encoding from what is desired.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1355 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356 preferred, because it is much faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360 non-zero for failure.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1364 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 set charconvert=CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 fun CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 system("recode "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 return v:shell_error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1376 < The related Vim variables are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379 v:fname_in name of the input file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 v:fname_out name of the output file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1389
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395 feature}
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1396 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1397 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398 preferred indent style.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1402 external program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405 option or 'indentexpr'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1413 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1415 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417 empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1418 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1419 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1420
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1421 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1422 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1423 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1424 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1426 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1427 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1428 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1429 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1431
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1432 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1433 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1434 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1435 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1436 {not available when compiled without both the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1439 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1440 an appropriate place (inside {}).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1443 "if,If,IF".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1444
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1445 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1447 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451 feature is included}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 This option is a list of comma separated names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1453 These names are recognized:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1454
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1458 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1459 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1460 or not. The clipboard register can always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1462 |gui-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1463
2654
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1464 unnamedplus A variant of "unnamed" flag which uses the clipboard
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1465 register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of register '*' for
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1466 all operations except yank. Yank shall copy the text
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1467 into register '+' and also into '*' when "unnamed" is
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1468 included.
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
1469 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
2654
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1470 Availability can be checked with: >
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1471 if has('unnamedplus')
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1472 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1473 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1474 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1475 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476 windowing system's global selection or put the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 "autoselect" flag is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 Also applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1483
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486
1904
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1487 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1488 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1489 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1490 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1491 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
2240
6b4879aea261 Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2220
diff changeset
1492 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
6b4879aea261 Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2220
diff changeset
1493 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
1904
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1494 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1495 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1496
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1497 exclude:{pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1499 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500 connection will be made to the X server. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501 useful in this situation:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502 - Running Vim in a console.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1503 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504 display.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1505 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1506 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1507 To never connect to the X server use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1508 exclude:.*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1509 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1510 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1511 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1512 cannot be accessed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1513 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1514 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1515 The rest of the option value will be used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1516 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1517
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1518 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1520 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523 |hit-enter| prompts.
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
1524 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
1525 page can have a different value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1530 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1531 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1532 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1533 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1534
2608
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1535 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1536 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1537 local to window
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1538 {not in Vi}
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1539 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1540 feature}
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1541 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1542 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1543 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1544 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1545 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1546
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1547 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1548 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1549 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1550 <
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1551 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1552 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1553
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1559 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1560 |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1563 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1565 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1566 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1567 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1568 window possible: >
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1569 :set columns=9999
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1570 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 'comments' 'com' string (default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1579 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581 insert a space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1589 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1590 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1591 |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1592
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1593 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1594 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1595 file is found)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1596 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1597 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1598 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1599 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1600 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1601 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1602 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1603 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1604 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1605 very start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1606 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1607 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1608 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1609 option.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1610 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1611 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1612 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1613 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1614 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1615 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1616 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1617 |posix-compliance|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1619 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1620 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1621 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1622 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1623 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1624 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1625 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1626 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1627 See also 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1628
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1629 option + set value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1630
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1631 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1632 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1633 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1634 'backspace' "" normal backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1635 'backup' off no backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1636 'cindent' off no C code indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1637 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1638 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1639 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1640 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1641 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1642 'digraph' off no digraphs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1643 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1644 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1645 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1646 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1647 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1648 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1649 'history' + 0 no commandline history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1650 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1651 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1652 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1653 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1654 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1655 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1656 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1657 characters and '_'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1658 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1659 'modeline' + off no modelines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660 'more' + off no pauses in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 'revins' off no reverse insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662 'ruler' off no ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1664 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1665 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1666 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1667 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1668 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1669 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1670 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1671 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1672 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1673 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1674 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1675 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1676 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1677 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1678 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1679 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1680 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1681 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1682 'writebackup' on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1683
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1684 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1685 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1686 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1687 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1688 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1689 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1690 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1691 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1692 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1693 w scan buffers from other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1694 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1695 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1696 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1697 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
1698 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 patterns are valid too. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 are valid too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705 i scan current and included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1708 ] tag completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 t same as "]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714 whole-line completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1716 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717 1. the current buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 2. buffers in other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719 3. other loaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 4. unloaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721 5. tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722 6. included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1725 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1726 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1728 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1729 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1730 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1731 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1732 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1733 or |+insert_expand| features}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1734 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1735 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1736 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1737 invoked and what it should return.
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
1738 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
1739 security reasons.
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
1740
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1741 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1742 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1743 global
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1744 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1745 |+insert_expand| feature}
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1746 {not in Vi}
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1747 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1748 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1749
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1750 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1751 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1752 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1753
707
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1754 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
1755 Useful when there is additional information about the
707
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1756 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1757
836
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1758 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1759 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1760 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1761 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1762 used.
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1763
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1764 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1765 completion in the preview window. Only works in
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1766 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1767
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1768
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1769 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1770 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1771 local to window
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1772 {not in Vi}
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1773 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1774 feature}
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1775 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1776 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1777 other lines.
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1778 n Normal mode
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1779 v Visual mode
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1780 i Insert mode
2382
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1781 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1782
2400
e6f1424dd66a Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2394
diff changeset
1783 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
2382
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1784 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1785 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1786 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1787 you can see what you are doing.
2380
b47748aa3236 Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
1788 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
b47748aa3236 Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
1789 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1790
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1791
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1792 'conceallevel' 'cole' *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1793 number (default 0)
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1794 local to window
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1795 {not in Vi}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1796 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1797 feature}
2340
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1798 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1799 is shown:
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1800
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1801 Value Effect ~
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1802 0 Text is shown normally
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1803 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1804 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1805 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1806 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1807 space).
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1808 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1809 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1810 custom replacement character defined (see
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1811 |:syn-cchar|).
2349
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1812 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1813
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1814 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1815 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1816 option.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1817
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1818 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1819 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1820 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1821 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1822 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1823 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1824 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1825 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1826 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1827 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828 command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1836 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837 three methods of console input are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839 on on or off direct console input
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840 off on BIOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841 off off STDIN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1852 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1853 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1854 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 Also see 'preserveindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 Vi default: all flags)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1863 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1864 this indicates vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865 not being vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 Commas can be added for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1871 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1872 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1873 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1874 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1875 POSIX specification.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877 contains behavior ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878 *cpo-a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1881 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 *cpo-A*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 *cpo-b*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1889 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 See also |map_bar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 *cpo-B*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 ('<' excluded in both cases)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 *cpo-c*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 next line. When not present searching continues
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910 *cpo-C*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 *cpo-d*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 tags file in the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 *cpo-D*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 |t|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921 *cpo-e*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928 *cpo-E*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 *cpo-f*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 *cpo-F*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 argument will set the file name for the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1941 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 *cpo-g*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1944 *cpo-H*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1945 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1946 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1947 the last blank.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948 *cpo-i*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950 leave it modified.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1951 *cpo-I*
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1952 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1953 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1954 *cpo-j*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 *cpo-J*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1959 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1960 white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961 *cpo-k*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966 being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969 Also see the '<' flag below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 *cpo-K*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975 *cpo-l*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1977 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1978 See |/[]|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1980 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
1981 Also see |cpo-\|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1982 *cpo-L*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1983 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 *cpo-m*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1988 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991 *cpo-M*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1994 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1995 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 *cpo-n*
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
1997 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
1998 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
1999 lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2000 *cpo-o*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 next search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 *cpo-O*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 *cpo-p*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 slightly better algorithm is used.
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2011 *cpo-P*
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2012 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2013 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2014 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2015 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2016 *cpo-q*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2017 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2018 position where it would be when joining two lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 *cpo-r*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 command, instead of the actually used search string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 *cpo-R*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025 *cpo-s*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2028 And it is the default. If not present the options are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029 set when the buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 *cpo-S*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 The options are set to the values in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 buffer options global to all buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 's' 'S' copy buffer options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040 no no when buffer created
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 *cpo-t*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 last used search pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048 *cpo-u*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2049 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 *cpo-v*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056 *cpo-w*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058 character and not all blanks until the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059 next word.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2060 *cpo-W*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2063 *cpo-x*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2064 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2065 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2066 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2067 *cpo-X*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2068 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2069 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2070 and a count.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2071 *cpo-y*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2072 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2073 *cpo-Z*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2074 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2075 don't reset 'readonly'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076 *cpo-!*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 used -filter- command is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080 *cpo-$*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086 point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 *cpo-%*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2100 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2101 This flag is also used for other features, such as
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2102 C-indenting.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2103 *cpo--*
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2104 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2105 it would go above the first line or below the last
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2106 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2107 last line, unless it already was in that line.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2108 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2109 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2110 *cpo-+*
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2111 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2112 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2113 itself may still be different from its file.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
2114 *cpo-star*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 *cpo-<*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2120 menu commands. For example, the command
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124 Also see the 'k' flag above.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2125 *cpo->*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2126 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2127 the appended text.
2925
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2128 *cpo-;*
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2129 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2130 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2131 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2132 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
2133 following occurrence.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2134
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2135 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2136 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2137
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2138 contains behavior ~
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
2139 *cpo-#*
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2140 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2141 *cpo-&*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2142 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2143 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2144 This flag is tested when exiting.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2145 *cpo-\*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2146 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2147 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
488
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2148 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2149 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2150 Also see |cpo-l|.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2151 *cpo-/*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2152 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2153 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2154 *cpo-{*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2155 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2156 at the start of a line.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2157 *cpo-.*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2158 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2159 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2160 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2161 opened file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2162 *cpo-bar*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2163 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2164 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2165 with system specific functions.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2166
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2168 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2169 'cryptmethod' string (default "zip")
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2170 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2171 {not in Vi}
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2172 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
2184
5028c4d6d825 Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2180
diff changeset
2173 *pkzip*
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2174 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2175 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
2184
5028c4d6d825 Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2180
diff changeset
2176 *blowfish*
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2177 blowfish Blowfish method. Strong encryption. Requires Vim 7.3
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2178 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older.
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2179 This adds a "seed" to the file, every time you write
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2180 the file the encrypted bytes will be different.
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2181
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2182 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2183 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2184 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2185 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2186 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2187 modifications. Also see |:X|.
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2188
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2189 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2190 the value "zip". When setting the local value to an empty string the
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2191 buffer will use the global value.
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2192
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2193 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2194 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2195 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2196
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2197
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2201 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2202 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2203 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2204 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2205 See |cscopepathcomp|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2214 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2217 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221 or |+quickfix| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224 See |cscopequickfix|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225
2873
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2226 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'*
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2227 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2228 global
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2229 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2230 feature}
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2231 {not in Vi}
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2232 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2233 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2234 See |cscoperelative|.
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2235
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2240 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2243 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2246 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252 |cscopetagorder|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2265 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2266 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2267 local to window
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2268 {not in Vi}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2269 {not available when compiled without the |+cursorbind|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2270 feature}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2271 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2272 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2273 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2274 column. This option is useful for viewing the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2275 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2276 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2302
diff changeset
2277 taken into account.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2278
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2279
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2280 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2281 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2282 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2283 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2284 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2285 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2286 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2287 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2288 slower.
826
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2289 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2290 these autocommands: >
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2291 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2292 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2293 <
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2294
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2295 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2296 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2297 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2298 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2299 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2300 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2301 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2302 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2303 redrawing slower.
818
1f929f3ca806 updated for version 7.0c03
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2304 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
825
6675076019ae updated for version 7.0d
vimboss
parents: 824
diff changeset
2305 easier to see the selected text.
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2306
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2307
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308 *'debug'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309 'debug' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 {not in Vi}
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2312 These values can be used:
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2313 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2314 anyway.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2315 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2316 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2317 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2318 produced.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2319 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2320 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2321 'indentexpr'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323 *'define'* *'def'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2327 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333 or backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2334 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335 useful, to include const type declarations: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2337 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 default) the character along with its combining characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348 deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353 to remove only the combining ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2359 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2364 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2365 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell|
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2366 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
99
04f2e519ab18 updated for version 7.0038
vimboss
parents: 82
diff changeset
2369 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 Where to find a list of words?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2377 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380 'diff' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2382 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2383 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2386 between files. See |vimdiff|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2405 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 synchronized with a window that has inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2410 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412 is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 See |fold-diff|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426 of the "diff" command for what this does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428 white space, but not leading white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2430 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2431 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2432
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2433 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2434 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2435
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2436 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2437 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2438
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2441 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2442 :set diffopt=
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2443 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2448 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2454
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455 *'directory'* *'dir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2456 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2457 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2459 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2462 possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 impossible!).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2469 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2470 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
459
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2472 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2473 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2474 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2475 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
2476 On Win32, when a separating comma is following, you must use "//",
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
2477 since "\\" will include the comma in the file name.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2479 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2484 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495 home directory is tried first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2496 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2497 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2498 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2499 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2500 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2502
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503 *'display'* *'dy'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 'display' 'dy' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2505 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508 flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2510 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513 instead of using ^C and ~C.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2514
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2515 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2517 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2519 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524 both width and height of windows is affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2527 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2529 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531 also 'gdefault' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 Switching this option on is discouraged!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2535 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2536 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2537 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2538 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2541 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2542 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2543 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2544
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2545 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2546 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2548 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2550 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2551 corrupt the text.
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2552
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2556 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2557 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2558 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2559 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2561 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2562 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2563 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2564
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2565 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2566 can use: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2567 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2568 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2569 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2570 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2571 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2572 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2573
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2574 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2575 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2576
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2577 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2578 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2579 to '-' signs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2580 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2581 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2582 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2585 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2586 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2591 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2593 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2595
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2596 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2597 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2604 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612 it if you want to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2619 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2620 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2621 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2622 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2623 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2624 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2625 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
1354
10a1b67c0885 updated for version 7.1-068
vimboss
parents: 1263
diff changeset
2627 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
10a1b67c0885 updated for version 7.1-068
vimboss
parents: 1263
diff changeset
2628 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2629 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2630 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2631 the future).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2634 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2636 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
2638 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2639 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2640 the "indent" program is used.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2641 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2642 about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2643 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2644 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2646 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2647 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2648 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2649 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2650 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2651 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2652 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2653 screen flash or do nothing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2654
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2655 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2656 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2657 others: "errors.err")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2658 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2659 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2663 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 following argument. See |-q|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2666 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2672 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2673 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2674 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2675 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2676 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2677 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2678 (see |errorformat|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2680 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2681 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2682 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2683 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2684 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2685 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2686 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2687 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2688 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2689 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2690 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2691 won't work by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2692 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2693 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2694
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2695 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2696 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2697 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2698 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2699 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2700 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2701 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
2702 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
2703 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2704 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2705 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2706 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2707 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2708 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2709 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2710 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2711 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2712 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2713 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2714 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2715 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2717 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2718 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2719 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2721 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2722 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2723 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2724 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2725 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2726 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2727 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2728
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2729 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2731 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2732 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2733 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2734 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2735 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2736
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2737 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2738 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2739 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2740 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2741 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2742 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2743 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2745 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2746 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2747 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2748 characters may be lost!
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2749
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2750 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2751 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2752 |mbyte-conversion|.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2753
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2754 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2755 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2756 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2757 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2758 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2759
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2760 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2761 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2762 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2763 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2764 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2765 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2766
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2767 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2768 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2769
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2770 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2771 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2772 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2773 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2774
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2776
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2777 *'fe'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2778 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2779 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2781
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2782 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2783 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2784 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2785 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2786 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2787 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2788 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2789 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2790 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2791 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2792 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2793 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2794 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2795 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2796 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2797 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2798 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2799 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2800 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2801 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2802 that can't be converted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2803 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2804 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2805 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2806 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2807 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2808 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2809 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2810 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2811 non-blank characters.
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2812 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2813 not used.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2814 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2815 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2816 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2817 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2818 an empty file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2819 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2820 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2821 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2822 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2823 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2824 accepted.
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2825 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2826 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2827 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2828 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
777
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2829 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2830 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2831 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2832 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2833 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2834 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2835 file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2836 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2837 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2838 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2839 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2840 is read.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2842 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2843 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2844 Unix default: "unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2845 Macintosh default: "mac")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2846 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2847 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2848 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2849 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2850 dos <CR> <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2851 unix <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2852 mac <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2853 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2854 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2855 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2856 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2857 works like it was set to "unix'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2858 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2859 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2860 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2861 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2862 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2863 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2864 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2866 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2867 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2868 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2869 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2870 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2871 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2872 Vi others: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2873 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2874 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2875 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2876 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2877 buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2878 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2879 always. It is not set automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2880 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2881 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2882 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2883 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2884 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2885 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2886 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2887 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2888 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2889 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2890 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2891 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
2587
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2892 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if 'fileformats'
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2893 includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2894 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2895 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2896 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2897 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2898 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
2899 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2900 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2901 'fileformats' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2902 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904 file only, the option is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2906
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
2907 Note that when Vim starts up with an empty buffer this option is not
2681
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
2908 used. Set 'fileformat' in your .vimrc instead.
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
2909
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2911 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2912 done:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2913 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2914 format will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2915 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2916 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2917 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2918 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2919 Also see |file-formats|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2920 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2921 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2922 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2923 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2924 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2925
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2926 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2927 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2928 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2929 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2930 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2934 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2935 name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2936 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2937 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2941 Example, for in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2942 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2943 |FileType| |filetypes|
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2944 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2945 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2946 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2947 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2948 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
2949 one dot may appear.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2950 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2951 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2952 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2953
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2954 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2955 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2956 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2957 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2958 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2959 and |+folding| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2960 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2961 It is a comma separated list of items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2962
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2963 item default Used for ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2964 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2965 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2966 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2967 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2968 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2969
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2970 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2971 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2972 otherwise.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2974 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2975 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2976 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2977 be used when there is highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2978
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
2979 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
2980
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2981 The highlighting used for these items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2982 item highlight group ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2983 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2984 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2985 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2986 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2987 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2988
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2989 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2990 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2991 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2992 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2993 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2994 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2995 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2996 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2997 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2998
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2999 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3000 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3001 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3002 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3003 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3004 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3005 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3006 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3007 automatically close when moving out of them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3008
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3009 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3011 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3012 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3013 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3014 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3015 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3016 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3017 value is 12.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3018 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3019
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3020 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3021 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3022 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3023 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3024 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3025 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3026 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3027 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3028 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3029 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3030 'foldenable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3031 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3032 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3034 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3035 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3036 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3037 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3038 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3039 or |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3040 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3041 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3042
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3043 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3044 |sandbox-option|.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3045 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3046 on.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3047
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3048 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3049 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3050
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3051 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3052 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3053 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3054 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3055 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3056 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3057 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3058 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3059 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3060 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3061
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3062 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3063 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3064 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3065 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3066 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3067 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3068 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3070 close fewer folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3075 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3076 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3077 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3078 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3079 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3081 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3084 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3085 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3087 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3088 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3090 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3091 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3092 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3093 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3094 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3095 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3096 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3097 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3098 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3099 See |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3101 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3103 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3105 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3106 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3107 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3108 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3109 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3110 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3111 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3112 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3113 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3114
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3115 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3116 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3117 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3118 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3119 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120 feature}
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3121 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3122 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3123 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3124 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
3125 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3128
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3129 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3133 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3140 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 search,tag,undo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3143 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 list of items.
2625
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3149 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3150 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3151 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3152
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 item commands ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3154 all any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3156 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3157 insert any command in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3158 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3159 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 percent "%"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3164 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3165 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3167 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3168 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3169 whole closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3170 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3171 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3172 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3173 when text is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3174 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3175 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3177 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3178 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3179 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3180 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3181 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3182 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3185
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3186 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3187 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3188
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3189 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3190 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3191
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3192 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3193 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3194 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3195 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3196 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3197 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3198 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3199 be inserted for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3200 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3201 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3202 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3203 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3204
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3205 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3206 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3207 local to buffer
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3208 {not in Vi}
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3209 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3210 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3211 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
3212 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3213 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3214 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3215 like there is no match.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3216 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3217 character and white space.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3218
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3219 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3220 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3221 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3222 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3224 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3225 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3226 such a program.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3227 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3228 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3229 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3230 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3231 about including spaces and backslashes.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3232 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3233 |sandbox-option|.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3234
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3235 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3236 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3237 local to buffer
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3238 {not in Vi}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3239 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3240 feature}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3241 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
2350
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3242 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3243 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3244
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3245 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3246 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3247 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
2350
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3248 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3249 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3250 it yet!
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3251
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3252 Example: >
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
3253 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3254 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3255 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3256
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3257 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3258 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3259 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3260 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
2298
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3261 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3262
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3263 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3264 the internal format mechanism.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3265
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3266 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
3267 |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, since changing
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
3268 the buffer text is not allowed.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3269
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3270 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3271 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3272 global
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3273 {not in Vi}
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3274 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3275 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3276 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3277 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3278 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3279 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3280 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3281 off.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3282 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3283
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3284 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3285 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3286 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3287 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3288 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3289 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3290 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3291 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3293 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3294 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3295 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3296 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3297
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3298 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3300 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3301 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3302 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3303 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3304 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3305 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3306 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3308 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3309 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3310 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3311 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3312 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3313 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3314 {not in Vi}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3315 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3316 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3317 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3318 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3319 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3320 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3321 also work well with a single file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3322 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
3323 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
657
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3324 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3325 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3326 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3327 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3328 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3329 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3330 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3331 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3333 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3334 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3335 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3336 o:hor50-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3337 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3338 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3339 sm:block-Cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3340 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3341 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3342 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3343 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3344 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3345 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3346 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3347 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3348 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3349 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3350 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3351 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3352 horizontal cursor.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3353 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3355 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3356 mode-list and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3361 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3362 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367 ci Command-line Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368 cr Command-line Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 a all modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3371 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375 [only one of the above three should be present]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3376 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3377 blinkon{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378 blinkoff{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3379 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3381 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3383 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3385 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 executing a command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3391 |xterm-blink|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3392 {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3393 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3394 for the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3395 {group-name}/{group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3396 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3397 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3398 are. |language-mapping|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3399
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3400 Examples of parts:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3401 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3402 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3403 highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3404 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3405 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3406 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3410 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3411 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3412 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3414
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3415 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3416 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3417 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3419 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
3420 *E235* *E596*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3423 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3424 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3425 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3426 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 The first valid font is used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3430
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3431 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3432 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3433
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3439 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3441
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3442 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3443 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3444 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3445 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3446 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3447 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3448
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3449 For Win32, GTK, Motif, Mac OS and Photon: >
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3450 :set guifont=*
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3451 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3452
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3453 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3454 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3455
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3456 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3457 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3458 < That's all. XLFDs are not used. For Chinese this is reported to work
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3459 well: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3460 if has("gui_gtk2")
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3461 set guifont=Bitstream\ Vera\ Sans\ Mono\ 12,Fixed\ 12
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3462 set guifontwide=Microsoft\ Yahei\ 12,WenQuanYi\ Zen\ Hei\ 12
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3463 endif
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3464 <
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3465 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3466 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
853
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3467 < Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems.
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3468 *E236*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3470 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3471 mono-spaced fonts look best.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3472
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3473 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3474 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3475
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3476 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3477 - takes these options in the font name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3478 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3479 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3480 b - bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3481 i - italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3482 u - underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3483 s - strikeout
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3484 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3485 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3486 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3487 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
3488 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3489
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3490 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3491 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3492 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3493 - Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3494 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3495 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3496 < See also |font-sizes|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3501 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3502 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3503 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3504 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3507 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508 |xfontset|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3510 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 |:highlight| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3512 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3513 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3514 'guifontset' will fail.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3515 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3516 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3517 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3518 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3519 fontset names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3520 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3521 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3522 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3523 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3524 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3525 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3526 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3528 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3529 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3530 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3531 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3532 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3533
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3534 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3535
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3536 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3537 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3538 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3539 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3541
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3542 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3543
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3546 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3547 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550 made by Pango/Xft.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3555 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3556 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3557 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3558 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3559 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3560 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3561 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3562 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3563
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3564 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3565 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3566 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3570 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572 GUI should be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 Valid letters are as follows:
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3577 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591 The same applies to the modeless selection.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3592 *'go-A'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3593 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594 applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 "" - -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598 "a" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599 "A" - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 "aA" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3602 *'go-c'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604 choices.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3605 *'go-e'*
697
f08390485cd3 updated for version 7.0210
vimboss
parents: 694
diff changeset
3606 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3607 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3608 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3609 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
3610 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3611 *'go-f'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3615 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 foreground. |gui-fork|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3618 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3619 *'go-i'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3623 *'go-m'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3624 'm' Menu bar is present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3625 *'go-M'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3626 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3628 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3631 *'go-g'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3632 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3634 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3635 *'go-t'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3636 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3637 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3638 *'go-T'*
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3639 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3640 and Athena GUIs.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3641 *'go-r'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3642 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3643 *'go-R'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3645 split window.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3646 *'go-l'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3648 *'go-L'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650 split window.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3651 *'go-b'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3652 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3653 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3654 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3655 *'go-h'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3662 *'go-v'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 vertical layout is used anyway.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3666 *'go-p'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3667 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3668 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3669 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3670 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3671 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3672 *'go-F'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3673 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3674
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3675
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3676 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677 'guipty' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3680 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3683
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3684 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3685 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3686 global
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3687 {not in Vi}
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3688 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3689 with the |+windows| feature}
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3690 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3691 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3692 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3693
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3694 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3695 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3696
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3697 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3698 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3699 used.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3700
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3701 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3702 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3703 global
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3704 {not in Vi}
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3705 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3706 with the |+windows| feature}
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3707 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3708 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3709 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3710 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3711 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3712 <
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3713
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3716 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3717 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3718 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3719 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3721 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3724 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3725 spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3726 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3729 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3733 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3740
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3744 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3745 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3747 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3748 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3750 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3751 language and not in the English help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3752 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3753 :set helplang=de,it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3754 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3755 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3756 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3757 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3758 See |help-translated|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3759
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3760 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3761 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3762 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3763 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3764 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3765 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3766 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3767 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3768 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3769 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3770 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
3771 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3772 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3773 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3774 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3776 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3777 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3778 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3779 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3780 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,N:CursorLineNr,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3781 r:Question,s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3782 c:VertSplit, t:Title,v:Visual,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3783 w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3784 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3785 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3786 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3787 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,-:Conceal,
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3788 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3789 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3790 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3791 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3792 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3793 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3794 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3795 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3796 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3797 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3798 characters from 'showbreak'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3799 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800 things in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3802 h (obsolete, ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
3807 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
3808 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3809 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' is set.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3811 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3815 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818 |xterm-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3820 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3823 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3824 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3825 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3826 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3828 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
2337
a0f87fc19d1d Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2324
diff changeset
3829 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3830 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3831 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3832 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3833 (see 'conceallevel')
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3834 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3835 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3836 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3837 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3838
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839 The display modes are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
205
d292c40ca788 updated for version 7.0060
vimboss
parents: 199
diff changeset
3845 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 n no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 - no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3848 : use a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3849 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3851 for an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3858 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3859 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3860 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3861 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 |+extra_search| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3864 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3865 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3866 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3867 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868 are not applied.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3871 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3872 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
3873 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3874 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3875 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3876 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3878 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3879 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3880 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883 *'history'* *'hi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 20, Vi default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3885 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3886 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3887 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3888 are remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3901 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3902 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3903
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3904 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3905 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3907 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3908 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3909 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3910 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3911 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3912 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3913 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3914
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3915 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3916 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3924 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3930 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 *'iconstring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 'iconstring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943 Does not work for MS Windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3947 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 'titlestring' for example settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3950
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3951 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3952 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3953 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3955 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956 Also see 'smartcase'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3957 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3958 |/ignorecase|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3959
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3960 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3963 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3964 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
2209
d0ddf7ba1630 Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
3965 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3967 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3969 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970 tells Vim what the key is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 Format:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975 S Shift key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 L Lock key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 C Control key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978 1 Mod1 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 2 Mod2 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 3 Mod3 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 4 Mod4 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 5 Mod5 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3983 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3984 both shift+ctrl+space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3985 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 :set imactivatekey=S-space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3996 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3997 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4001 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 characters with dead keys.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4004 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4005 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4008 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4009 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4010 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4012 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013 may change in later releases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 Insert mode. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4025 or |global-ime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4026 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4027 this can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4028 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030 mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4031 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 |i_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4034 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4039 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4041 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4042 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4043 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4044 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4045 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4046 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4047 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4048 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4049 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4050 |c_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4051 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4052 option to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4053 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4054 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4055
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4056 *'include'* *'inc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4057 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4058 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4059 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4060 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4061 |+find_in_path| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4062 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4063 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4064 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4065 "]I", "[d", etc.
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4066 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4067 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4068 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4069 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4070 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4071 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4072 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4074 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4075 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4076 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4077 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078 {not available when compiled without the
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4079 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4080 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4081 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4084
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4086 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087 Also used for |<cfile>|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4089 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4090 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4091
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4092 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4093 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4094
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4097 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4098 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 {not available when compiled without the
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4100 |+extra_search| features}
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4101 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4102 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4103 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4104 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4105 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4106 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4107 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4108 cursor to the match.
1521
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4109 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4110 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4111 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4112 are typing the pattern.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4113 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4114 See also: 'hlsearch'.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4115 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
2302
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4116 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4117 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4118 converted to lowercase.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4119 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4120 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4121 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4123 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4124 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4125 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4126 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4127 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 or |+eval| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4131 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
2833
c869ff170ddc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
4133 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
c869ff170ddc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
4134 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4135 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4137 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4140 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4141 used for the indent).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4143 and |lispindent()|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4146 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4147 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 "msg".
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4151 See |indent-expression|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4154 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4155 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4156
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4157 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4158 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4159
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4160
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4161 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4162 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4163 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4164 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4165 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4166 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4167 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4168 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4169 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4170 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4171
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4172 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4173 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4174 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4177 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4178 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4179 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4180 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4181 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4182 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4183 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4185 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4186 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4187 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4188 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4189 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4190 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4191 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4192 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
4197 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
4198 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4200 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4202 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4203 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4204 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4205 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4206 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4207 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4208 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4209 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4211 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4213 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4219 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4220 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4221 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4222 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4223 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4224 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4225 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4226 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4227 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4228 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4229 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4230 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4231 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4233 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4234 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4235 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4236 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4237 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4238 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4239 cmd.exe.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4242 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4243 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 not work for digits). Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4247 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4251 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4252 option or the end of a range. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4253 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4256 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4257 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4258 case ASCII letters.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4259 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4260 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4261 expected. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4262 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4263 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4264 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4265 comma, plus <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4266 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4267
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4268 *'isident'* *'isi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4269 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4270 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4271 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4272 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4273 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4274 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4275 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4276 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4277 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4278 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4279 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4280 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4291 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4295 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4296 command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4297 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4298 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4299 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4301 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4302 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4303 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4304 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4305 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4306 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4307 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4308 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4309 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4310 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4312 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4313 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4314 32 - 126 always single characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4315 127 "^?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4316 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4317 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4318 255 "~?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4319 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4320 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4321 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4322 displayed as <xx>.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4323 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4324 |hl-SpecialKey|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4325
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4326 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4327 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4328 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4329 replacement character will be shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4330 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4331 There is no option to specify these characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4333 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4337 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4338 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4340 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342 *'key'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4343 'key' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4344 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345 {not in Vi}
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2265
diff changeset
4346 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2265
diff changeset
4347 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4348 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
4349 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4350 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352 :set key=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4353 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4354 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4355 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4356 be careful not to make a typing error!
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
4357 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
4358 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4360 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4361 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4362 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4363 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4364 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4365 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4366 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4367 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4368 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4369 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4370 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4372 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4373 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4374 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4377 can do. These values can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 present in 'selectmode').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4395 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4396 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4397 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4398 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4399 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4400 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4406 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4407 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4408 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4409 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4410 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4411 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4412 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4413 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4414 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4415 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4416 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4417 mapped in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4418
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4419 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4420 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 part can be in one of two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4427 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4431 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4432 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4433
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4434 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4435 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4436 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4437 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4438 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4439 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4440 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4441 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4442 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4443 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4444 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4446 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4447 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4448 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4449 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4450 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4451 |+multi_lang| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4452 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4453 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4454 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4455 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4456 matter what $LANG is set to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4457 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4458 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4459 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4460 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4461 the English menus: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4462 :set langmenu=none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4463 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4464 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4465 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4466 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4467 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4468 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4469 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4471 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4472 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4473 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4474 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4475 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4476 status line:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4477 0: never
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4478 1: only if there are at least two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 2: always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4489 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490 update use |:redraw|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4496 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 If on Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 value of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 This option is not used when the 'wrap' option is off or 'list' is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 with the right amount of white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 *'lines'* *E593*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510 Number of lines of the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4511 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
4512 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4513 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4514 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518 :set lines=999
571
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4519 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4520 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528 {only in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4530 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4532 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4533 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4534 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4535 though!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4537 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4538 'lisp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4539 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4540 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4541 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4542 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4543 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4544 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4545 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4546 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4547 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4548 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4553 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4554 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4555 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4556 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4557 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 |'lisp'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4562 *'list'* *'nolist'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4563 'list' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4564 local to window
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4565 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4566 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4567 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4568
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4569 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4570 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4571 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4572 :set list lcs=tab\ \
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4573 <
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4574 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4575 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576 changing the way tabs are displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4580 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4581 {not in Vi}
2458
22a6f99e6477 Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2426
diff changeset
4582 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
22a6f99e6477 Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2426
diff changeset
4583 comma separated list of string settings.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4584 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4585 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4586 line.
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4587 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4588 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4589 fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4590 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4591 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4592 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4593 trailing spaces are blank.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4594 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4595 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4596 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4597 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4598 is off and there is text preceding the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4599 visible in the first column.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
4600 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
4601 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4602 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
4603 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4604
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4605 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4606 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
4607 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4608
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4609 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4610 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4611 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4612 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4613 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4614 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail".
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4615 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4616
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4617 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4618 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623 of plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4624 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626
842
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4627 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4628 'macatsui' boolean (default on)
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4629 global
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4630 {only available in Mac GUI version}
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4631 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4632 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4633 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4634 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4635 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4636 to unset it: >
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4637 if exists('&macatsui')
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4638 set nomacatsui
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4639 endif
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4640 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4641 'termencoding'.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4642
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4643 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4644 'magic' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4645 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647 See |pattern|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4648 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4650 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
20
4ac1dce8dd5e updated for version 7.0012
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4651 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4652
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4653 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4654 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4655 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4656 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 and the |:grep| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4664 existing file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4665 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4666 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4667 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4668 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4669 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4670
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4671 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4672 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4673 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4674 {not in Vi}
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4675 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4676 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters, which are expanded to
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4677 the current and alternate file name. |:_%| |:_#|
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4678 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4679 about including spaces and backslashes.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4680 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4681 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4682 "myfilter" do it like this: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4683 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4684 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4685 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4686 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4687 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4688 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4689
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4690 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4691 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4692 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4693 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4695 other. Currently only single byte character pairs are allowed, and
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4696 they must be different. The characters must be separated by a colon.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4697 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4698 '>' (HTML): >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 :set mps+=<:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4701 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4702 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4703 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4704
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4705 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4706 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4707
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4708 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4709 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4710 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4711 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4716 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4717 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4718 global
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4719 {not in Vi}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4720 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4721 feature}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4722 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4723 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4724 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4725 Maximum value is 6.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4726 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4727 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4728 See |mbyte-combining|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4729
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4730 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4731 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4732 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4733 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4734 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4735 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4736 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4737 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4738 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4739 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4740 See also |:function|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4742 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4743 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4744 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4745 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4746 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4747 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4748 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4749 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4750 |key-mapping|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4751
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4752 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4753 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4754 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4755 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4756 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4757 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4758 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4759 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4760 other memory to be freed. The maximum usable value is about 2000000.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4761 Use this to work without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4762
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4763 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4764 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4765 global
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4766 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4767 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4768 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4769 *E363*
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4770 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4771 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4772 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4773 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4774 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4775 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4776
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4777 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4778 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4779 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4780 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4781 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4782 {not in Vi}
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4783 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4784 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4785 without a limit. On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4786 hey, do you really need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing?
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4787 Also see 'maxmem'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4789 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4790 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4791 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4794 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4798
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4799 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4800 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4801 global
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4802 {not in Vi}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4803 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4804 feature}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4805 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4806 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4807 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4808 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4809 this tuning is complicated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4810
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4811 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4812 {start},{inc},{added}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4813
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4814 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4815 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4816 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4817 memory that is available to Vim.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4818
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4819 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4820 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4821 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4822 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4823 will be allocated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4824
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4825 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4826 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4827 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4828 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4829 slower.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4830
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4831 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4832 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4833 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4834 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4835 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4836 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4837
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4838 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
4839 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
4840 Vi default: off)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4841 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4842 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4843 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4844 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4845 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4846 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4847 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4848 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4849 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4850 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4851
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4852 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4853 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4854 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4855 {not in Vi} *E21*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4856 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4857 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4858 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4860 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4861 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4862 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4863 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4864 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4865 when:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4866 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4867 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4868 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4869 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4870 when it was written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4871 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4872 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4873 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4874 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4875 reset.
3082
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
4876 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
4877 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
4878 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
4879 an explanation.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4880 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4881 will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4882
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4883 *'more'* *'nomore'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4884 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4885 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4886 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4887 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4888 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4889 listing continues until finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4890 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4891 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4892
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4893 *'mouse'* *E538*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4894 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4895 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4896 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4897 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4898 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4899 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4900 GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4901 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4902 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4903 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4904 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4905 c Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4906 h all previous modes when editing a help file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4907 a all previous modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4908 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4909 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4910 :set mouse=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4911 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4912 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4913
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4914 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4915
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4916 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4917 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4918 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4919 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4920
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4921 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4922 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4923 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4924 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4925 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4926 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4927 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4928 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4929 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4930 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4931
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4932 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4933 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4934 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4935 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4936 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4937 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4938 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4939
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4940 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4941 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4942 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4943 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4944 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4945 the right mouse button is used for:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4946 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4947 like in an xterm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4948 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4949 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4950 with Microsoft Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4951 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4952 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4953 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4954 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4955 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4956 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4957 end Visual mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4958 Overview of what button does what for each model:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4959 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4960 left click place cursor place cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4961 left drag start selection start selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4962 shift-left search word extend selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4963 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4964 right drag extend selection -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4965 middle click paste paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4966
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4967 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4968 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4969
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4970 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4971 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4972 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4974 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4975
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4976 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4977 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4978 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4979 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4980 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4981 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4982 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4983 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4984 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4985 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4986 and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4987 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4988 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4989 In a normal window: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4990 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4991 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4992 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4993 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4994 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4995 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4996 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4997
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4998 Others: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4999 c appending to the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5000 ci inserting in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5001 cr replacing in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5002 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5003 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5004 e any mode, pointer below last window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5005 s any mode, pointer on a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5006 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5007 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5008 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5009 a everywhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5010
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5011 The shape is one of the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5012 avail name looks like ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5013 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5014 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5015 w x beam I-beam
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5016 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5017 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5018 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5019 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5020 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5021 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5022 x crosshair like a big thin +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5023 x hand1 black hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5024 x hand2 white hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5025 x pencil what you write with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5026 x question big ?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5027 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5028 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5029 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5030
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5031 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5032 x for X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5033 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5034 pointer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5036 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5037 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5038 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5039 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5040 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5041
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5042 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5043 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5044 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5045 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5046 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5047 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5048 recognized as a multi click.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5049
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5050 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5051 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5052 global
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5053 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5054 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5055 feature}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5056 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5057 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5058
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5059 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5060 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5061 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5062 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5063 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5064 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5065 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5066 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5067 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3224
diff changeset
5068 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5069 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5070 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5071 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5072 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5073 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5074 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5075 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5076 recognized as octal or hex.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5078 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5079 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5080 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5081 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5082 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5083 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5084 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5085 number.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5086 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5087 characters are put before the number.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5088 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5089 the number.
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5090 When setting this option, 'relativenumber' is reset.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5091
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5092 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5093 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5094 local to window
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5095 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5096 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5097 feature}
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5098 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5099 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5100 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5101 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5102 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5103 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5104 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5105 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5106 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5107 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5108 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5109
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
5110 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
5111 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5112 local to buffer
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5113 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5114 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5115 or |+insert_expand| features}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
5116 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
5117 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5118 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5119 invoked and what it should return.
1004
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5120 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
859
99305c4c42d4 updated for version 7.0g02
vimboss
parents: 857
diff changeset
5121 |:filetype-plugin-on|
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5122
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5123
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
5124 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
1004
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5125 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5126 global
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5127 {not in Vi}
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5128 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5129 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5130 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5131 it is off by default.
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5132 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5133 result in editing a device.
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5134
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5135
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5136 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5137 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5138 global
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5139 {not in Vi}
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5140 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5141 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5142
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5143 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5144 security reasons.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5145
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5146
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5147 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5148 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5149 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5150 {not in Vi}
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5151 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5152
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5153
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5154 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
1564
8c9396275bfa updated for version 7.1-277
vimboss
parents: 1521
diff changeset
5155 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5156 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5157 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5158 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5159
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5160 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5161 'paste' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5162 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5163 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5164 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5165 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5166 unexpected effects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5167 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5168 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5169 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5170 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5171 mouse clicks itself.
148
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5172 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5173 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5174 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5175 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5176 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5177 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5178 - abbreviations are disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5179 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5180 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5181 - 'autoindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5182 - 'smartindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5183 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5184 - 'revins' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5185 - 'ruler' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5186 - 'showmatch' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5187 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5188 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5189 - 'lisp'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5190 - 'indentexpr'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5191 - 'cindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5192 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5193 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5194 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5195 set the 'paste' option again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5196 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5197 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5198 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5199 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5200 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5201
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5202 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5203 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5204 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5205 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5206 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5207 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5208 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5209 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5210 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5211 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5212 Command-line mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5213 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5214 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5215 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5216 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5217 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5218 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5219 :imap <F11> <nop>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5220 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5221 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5222 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5223 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5224 sequence.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5225 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5226
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5227 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5228 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5229 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5230 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5231 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5232 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5233 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5234 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5236 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E206*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5237 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5238 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5239 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5240 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5241 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5242 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5243 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5244 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5245 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5246 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5247 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5248 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5249 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5250 created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5251 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5252 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5253 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5254 recognized as a compressed file.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5255 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5256
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
5257 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5258 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5259 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5260 other systems: ".,,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5261 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5262 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5263 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5264 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5265 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5266 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5267 option may be relative or absolute.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5268 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5269 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5270 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5271 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5272 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5273 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5274 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5275 backslash: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5276 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5277 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5278 :set path=.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5279 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5280 commas: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5281 :set path=,,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5282 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5283 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5284 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5285 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5286 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5287 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5288 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5289 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5290 :set path=.,c:\\include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5291 < Or just use '/' instead: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5292 :set path=.,c:/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5293 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5294 the file!
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5295 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5296 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5297 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5298 'path', see |:checkpath|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5299 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5300 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5301 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5302 :set path-=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5303 < To add the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5304 :set path+=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5305 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5306 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5307 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5308 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5309 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5310 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5312 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5313 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5314 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5315 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5316 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5317 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5318 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5319 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5320 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5321 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5322 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5323 a Tab.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5324 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5325 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5326 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5327 Also see 'copyindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5328 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5330 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5331 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5332 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5333 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5334 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5335 |+quickfix| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5336 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5337 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5339 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5340 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5341 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5342 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5343 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5344 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5345 |+quickfix| features}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5346 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5347 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5348 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5349
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5350 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5351 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5352 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5353 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5354 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5355 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5356 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5357 See |pdev-option|.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5358 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5359 security reasons.
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5360
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5361 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5362 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5363 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5364 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5365 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5366 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5367 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5368 See |penc-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5370 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5371 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5372 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5373 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5374 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5375 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5376 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5377 See |pexpr-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5378
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5379 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5380 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5381 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5382 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5383 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5384 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5385 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5386 See |pfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5388 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5389 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5390 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5391 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5392 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5393 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5394 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5395 See |pheader-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5396
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5397 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5398 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5399 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5400 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5401 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5402 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5403 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5404 See |pmbcs-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5405
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5406 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5407 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5408 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5409 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5410 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5411 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5412 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5413 See |pmbfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5414
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5415 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5416 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5417 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5418 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5419 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5420 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5421 See |popt-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5422
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5423 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5424 'prompt' boolean (default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5425 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5426 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5427
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5428 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5429 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5430 global
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5431 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5432 |+insert_expand| feature}
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5433 {not in Vi}
853
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
5434 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
5435 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5436 |ins-completion-menu|.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5437
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5438
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
5439 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5440 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5441 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5442 {not in Vi}
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5443 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5444 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5445 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5446 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5447 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5448
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5449 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5450 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5451 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5452 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5453 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5454 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5455 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5456 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5457 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5458 set for the newly edited buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5459
1521
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5460 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5461 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5462 global
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5463 {not in Vi}
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5464 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5465 feature}
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5466 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5467 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch' and |:match| highlighting.
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5468 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5469 matches will be highlighted. This is used to avoid that Vim hangs
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5470 when using a very complicated pattern.
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5471
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5472 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5473 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5474 local to window
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5475 {not in Vi}
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5476 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2204
diff changeset
5477 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5478 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5479 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5480 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5481 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5482 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5483 'compatible' isn't set).
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5484 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5485 number.
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5486 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5487 characters are put before the number.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5488 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5489 the number.
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5490 When setting this option, 'number' is reset.
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5491
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5492 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5493 'remap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5494 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5495 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5496 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
717
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5497 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5498 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5499 old Vi scripts.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5501 *'report'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5502 'report' number (default 2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5503 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5504 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5505 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5506 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5507 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5508 instead of the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5509
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5510 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5511 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5512 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5513 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5514 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5515 happens when executing external commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5517 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5518 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5519 set t_ti= t_te=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5520 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5521 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5522 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5523
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5524 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5525 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5526 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5527 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5528 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5529 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5530 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5531 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5532 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5533 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5534
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5535 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5536 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5537 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5538 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5539 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5540 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5541 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5542 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5543 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5544 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5545 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5546 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5547 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5548 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5549 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5550
2341
9272cc83214f Minor runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2340
diff changeset
5551 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5552 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5553 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5554 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5555 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5556 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5557 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5558 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5559
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5560 search "/" and "?" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5561
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5562 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5563 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5564
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5565 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5566 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5567 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5568 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5569 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5570 |+cmdline_info| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5571 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5572 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5573 text in the file is shown on the far right:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5574 Top first line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5575 Bot last line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5576 All first and last line are visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5577 45% relative position in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5578 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5579 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5580 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5581 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5582 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5583 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5584 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5585 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5586 separated with a dash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5587 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5588 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5589 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5590 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5591 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5592 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5593
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5594 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5595 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5596 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5597 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5598 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5599 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5600 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5601 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
5602 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5603 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5604 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5605 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5606 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5607 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5608 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5609 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5610 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5611 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5612 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5613 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5614 $HOME/.vim/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5615 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5616 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5617 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5618 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5619 home:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5620 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5621 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5622 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5623 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5624 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5625 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5626 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5627 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5628 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5629 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5630 Choices:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5631 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5632 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5633 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5634 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5635 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5636 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5637 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5638 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5639 files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5640 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5641 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5642 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5643 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5644 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5645 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5646 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5647 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5648 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5649 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5650 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5651 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5652 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
5653 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5654 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5655 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5656
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5657 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5659 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5660 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5661 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5662 administrator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5663 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5664 *after-directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5665 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5666 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5667 defaults (rarely needed)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5668 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5669 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5670 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5671
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5672 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5673 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5674 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5675 wildcards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5676 See |:runtime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5677 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5678 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5679 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5680 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5681 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5682 files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5683 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5684 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5685 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5686 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5687 runtime files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5688 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5689 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5691 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5692 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5693 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5694 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5695 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5696 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5697 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5698 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5699 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5700 when lines wrap}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5701
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5702 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5703 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5704 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5705 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5706 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5707 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5708 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5709 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5710 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5711 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5712 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5713 interpreted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5714 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5715 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5716 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5717
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5718 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5719 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5720 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5721 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5722 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5723 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5724 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5725 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5726 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5727 height.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5728 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5729
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5730 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5731 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5732 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5733 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5734 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5735 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5736 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5737 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5738 when long lines wrap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5739 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5740 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5742 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5743 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5744 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5745 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5746 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5747 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5748 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5749 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
5750 Options.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5751 The following words are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5752 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5753 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5754 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5755 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5756 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5757 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5758 reach a position before the start or after the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5759 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5760 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5761 to the desired position when possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5762 When now making that window the current one, two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5763 things can be done with the relative offset:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5764 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5765 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5766 window. When going back to the other window, the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
5767 new relative offset will be used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5768 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5769 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5770 going back to the other window, it still uses the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5771 same relative offset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5772 Also see |scroll-binding|.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5773 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
5774 even when "ver" isn't there.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5776 *'sections'* *'sect'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5777 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5778 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5779 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5780 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5781 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5782
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5783 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5784 'secure' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5785 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5786 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5787 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5788 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5789 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5790 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5791 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5792 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5793 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5794 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5795 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5796
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5797 *'selection'* *'sel'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5798 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5799 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5800 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5801 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5802 in Visual and Select mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5803 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5804 value past line inclusive ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5805 old no yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5806 inclusive yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5807 exclusive yes no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5808 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5809 character past the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5810 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5811 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5812 selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5813 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5814 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5815 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5816
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5817 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5818
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5819 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5820 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5821 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5822 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5823 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5824 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5825 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5826 mouse when using the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5827 key when using shifted special keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5828 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5829 See |Select-mode|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5830 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5832 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5833 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
827
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
5834 help,options,tabpages,winsize")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5835 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5836 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5837 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5838 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5839 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5840 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5841 something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5842 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5843 blank empty windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5844 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5845 curdir the current directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5846 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5847 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5848 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5849 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
5850 String and Number types are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5851 help the help window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5852 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5853 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5854 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5855 options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5856 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5857 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5858 will become the current directory (useful with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5859 projects accessed over a network from different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5860 systems)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5861 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5862 slashes
827
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
5863 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
5864 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
5865 tab page separately
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5866 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5867 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5868 winpos position of the whole Vim window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5869 winsize window sizes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5870
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5871 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
5872 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
5873 with absolute paths.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5874 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5875 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5876 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5877
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5878 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5879 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5880 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5881 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5882 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5883 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5884 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5885 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5886 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5887 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5888 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5889 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5890 it in quotes. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5891 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5892 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5893 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5894 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5895 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5896 separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5897 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5898 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5899 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5900 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5901 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5902 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5903 filtering).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5904 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5905 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5906 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5907 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5908 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5909
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5910 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
3356
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3352
diff changeset
5911 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
3371
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
5912 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
5913 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5914 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5915 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5916 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5917 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5918 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5919 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
3082
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5920 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself).
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5921 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5922 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5923 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5924 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5925 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5926 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5928 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5929 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5930 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5931 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5932 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5933 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5934 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5935 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5936 including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5937 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5938 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5939 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5940 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5941 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5942 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5943 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5944 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
2788
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
5945 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
5946 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
5947 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
5948 "sh".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5949 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5950 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5951 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5952 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5953 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5954 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5955 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5956 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5957 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5958 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5959 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5960 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5961 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5962
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5963 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5964 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5965 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5966 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5967 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5968 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5969 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5970 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5971 probably not useful to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5972 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5973 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5974 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5975 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5976 user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5977 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5978 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5979
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5980 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5981 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5982 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5983 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5984 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5985 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5986 and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5987 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5988 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5989 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5990 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5991 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5992 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5993 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5994 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5995 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5996 ".exe" appended are checked for.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5997 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5998 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5999 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6000 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6001 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6002 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6003 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6004 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6005
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6006 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6007 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6008 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6009 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6010 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6011 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6012 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6013 forward slashes by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6014 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6015 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6016 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6017 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6018 separator. To test if this is so use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6019 if exists('+shellslash')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6020 <
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6021 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6022 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6023 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6024 {not in Vi}
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6025 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6026 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2925
diff changeset
6027 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2925
diff changeset
6028 later. You can check it with: >
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6029 :if has("filterpipe")
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6030 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6031 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6032 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6033 can be detected.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6034 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6035 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6036 'shelltemp' is off.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6037
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6038 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6039 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6040 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6041 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6042 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6043 which use a shell.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6044 0 and 1: always use the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6045 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6046 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6047 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6049 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6050 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6051
3371
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6052 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6053 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6054 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6055 global
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6056 {not in Vi}
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6057 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6058 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6059 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6060
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6061 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6062 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
3359
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6063 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6064 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6065 somewhere: "\""
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6066 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6067 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6068 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6069 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6070 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6071 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6072 to set both options.
3359
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6073 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6074 then ')"' is appended.
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6075 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
3352
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6076 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6077 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6078 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6079 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6080 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6081 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6082 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6083 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6084
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6085 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6086 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6087 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6088 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6089 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6090 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6091 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6092 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6093
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6094 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6095 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6096 local to buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6097 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6098 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6099
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6100 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6101 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6102 POSIX default: "A")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6103 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6104 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6105 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6106 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6107 It is a list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6108 flag meaning when present ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6109 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6110 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6111 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6112 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6113 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6114 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6115 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6116 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6117 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6118 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6119 a all of the above abbreviations
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6120
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6121 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6122 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6123 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6124 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6125 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6126 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6127 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6128 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6129 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6130 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6131 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6132 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6133 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6134 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6135 is found.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6136 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6137
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6138 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6139 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6140 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6141 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6142 Useful values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6143 shm= No abbreviation of message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6144 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6145 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6146
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6147 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6148 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6150 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6151 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6152 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6153 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6154 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6155 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6156 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6157 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6158 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6159 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6160 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6161 option is always on by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6163 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6164 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6165 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6166 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6167 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6168 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6169 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6170 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6171 :set showbreak=>\
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6172 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6173 this: >
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2302
diff changeset
6174 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6175 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6176 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6177 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6178 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6179 'highlight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6180 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6181 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6182 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6184 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6185 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6186 off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6187 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6188 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6189 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6190 |+cmdline_info| feature}
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6191 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6192 option off if your terminal is slow.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6193 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6194 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
2324
0a258a67051d In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2317
diff changeset
6195 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
0a258a67051d In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2317
diff changeset
6196 means two characters and six bytes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6197 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6198 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6199 {lines}x{columns}.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6200 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6201 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6202
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6203 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6204 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6205 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6206 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6207 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6208 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6209 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6210 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6211 required (coding style permitting).
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6212 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6213 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6214 match the typed text.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6216 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6217 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6218 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6219 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6220 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6221 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6222 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6223 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6224 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6225 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6226 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6227 blinking when showing the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6228 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6229 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6230 matches.
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6231 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6232 around |pi_paren.txt|.
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6233 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6234
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6235 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6236 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6237 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6238 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6239 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6240 this message.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6241 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6242 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6243 not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6244 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6245 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6246
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6247 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6248 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6249 global
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6250 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6251 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6252 feature}
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6253 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6254 will be displayed:
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6255 0: never
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6256 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6257 2: always
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6258 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6259 line.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6260 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6261
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6262 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6263 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6264 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6265 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6266 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6267 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6268 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6269 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6270 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6271 commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6273 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6274 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6275 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6276 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6277 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6278 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6279 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6280 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6281 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6282 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6283 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6284 close to the beginning of the line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6285 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6286
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6287 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6288 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6289 onto the "extends" character:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6291 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6292 :set sidescrolloff=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6295 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6296 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6297 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6298 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6299 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6300 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6301 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
6302 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6303 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6304 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6305 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6307 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6308 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6309 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6310 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6311 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6312 |+smartindent| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6313 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6314 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6315 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
6316 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
6317 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
6318 alternative.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6319 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6320 An indent is automatically inserted:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6321 - After a line ending in '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6322 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6323 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6324 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6325 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6326 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6327 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6328 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6329 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6330 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6331 right.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6332 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6333 is set smart indenting is disabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6335 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6336 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6337 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6338 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6339 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6340 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6341 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6342 line.
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6343 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6344 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6345 right |shift-left-right|.
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
6346 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6347 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6348 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6349 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6351 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6352 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6353 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6354 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6355 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6356 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6357 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6358 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6359 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6360 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6361 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6362 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6363 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6364 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6365 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6366 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6367 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6368
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6369 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6370 'spell' boolean (default off)
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6371 local to window
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6372 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6373 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6374 feature}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6375 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6376 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6377
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6378 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6379 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6380 local to buffer
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6381 {not in Vi}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6382 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6383 feature}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6384 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6385 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6386 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6387 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6388 Only used when 'spell' is set.
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6389 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6390 including spaces and backslashes.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6391 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6392 |set-spc-auto|.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6393
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6394 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6395 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6396 local to buffer
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6397 {not in Vi}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6398 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6399 feature}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6400 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
401
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
6401 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
6402 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6403 *E765*
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6404 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6405 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6406 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6407 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6408 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6409 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6410 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6411 ignoring the region.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6412 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6413 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6414 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6415 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6416 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6417 without region name will be found.
336
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
6418 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
6419 security reasons.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6420
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6421 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6422 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6423 local to buffer
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6424 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6425 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6426 feature}
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6427 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6428 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6429 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6430 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6431 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6432 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6433 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6434 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6435 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6436 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6437 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6438 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6439 Britain.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6440 *E757*
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6441 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6442 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6443 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6444 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6445 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6446 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6447 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6448 files twice.
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6449 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6450
653
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6451 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6452 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6453 will ask you if you want to download the file.
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6454
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6455 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6456 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6457 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6458 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6459
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6460
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6461 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6462 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6463 global
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6464 {not in Vi}
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6465 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6466 feature}
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6467 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6468 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6469 items:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6470
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6471 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6472 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6473 scoring to improve the ordering.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6474
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6475 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6476 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6477 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6478 word. That only works when the language specifies
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6479 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6480 better results.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6481
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6482 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6483 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6484 simple typing mistakes.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6485
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6486 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6487 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6488 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6489 minus two.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6490
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6491 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6492 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6493 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6494 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6495 theribal/terrible ~
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6496 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6497 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6498 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6499 comments.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6500 The file is used for all languages.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6501
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6502 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6503 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6504 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6505 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6506 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6507 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6508 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6509 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6510 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6511 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6512 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6513 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6514
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6515 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6516 appear several times in any order. Example: >
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6517 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6518 <
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6519 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6520 security reasons.
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6521
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6522
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6523 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6524 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6525 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6526 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6527 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6528 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6529 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6530 one. |:split|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6532 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6533 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6534 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6535 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6536 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6537 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6538 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6539 current one. |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6540
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6541 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6542 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6543 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6544 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6545 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6546 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6547 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6548 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6549 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6550 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6551 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6552 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6553 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6554 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6555
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6556 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6557 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
6558 global or local to window |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6559 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6560 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6561 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6562 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6563 Also see |status-line|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6564
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6565 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6566 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6567 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6568 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6569 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6570
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6571 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6572 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6573 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6574 < The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6575 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6576 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6577 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6578
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6579 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6580 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6581
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6582 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6583 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6585 field meaning ~
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6586 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6587 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6588 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6589 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6590 Value must be 50 or less.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6591 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6592 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6593 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6594 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6595 an exponential notation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6596 item A one letter code as described below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6598 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6599 second character in "item" is the type:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6600 N for number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6601 S for string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6602 F for flags as described below
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6603 - not applicable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6605 item meaning ~
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6606 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6607 directory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6608 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6609 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6610 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6611 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6612 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6613 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6614 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6615 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6616 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6617 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6618 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6619 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6620 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
2411
68e394361ca3 Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2400
diff changeset
6621 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6622 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6623 being used: "<keymap>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6624 n N Buffer number.
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6625 b N Value of character under cursor.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6626 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6627 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6628 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6629 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6630 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6631 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6632 l N Line number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6633 L N Number of lines in buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6634 c N Column number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6635 v N Virtual column number.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6636 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6637 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6638 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6639 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6640 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6641 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6642 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
6643 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6644 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6645 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6646 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6647 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6648 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6649 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6650 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6651 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6652 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6653 No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6654 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6655 No width fields allowed.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6656 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6657 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6658 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6659 windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6660 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6661 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6662 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6663 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6664 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6665
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6666 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6667 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6668 when flags are used like in the examples below.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6669
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6670 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6671 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6672 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6673 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6674 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6675 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6676 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6677 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6678 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6679 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6680 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6681 real current buffer.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6682
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6683 The 'statusline' option may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6684 |sandbox-option|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6685
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6686 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6687 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6688
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6689 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6690 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6691 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6692 :let &ro = &ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6693
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6694 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6695 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6696 described above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6697
199
3b32f6b507fa updated for version 7.0059
vimboss
parents: 189
diff changeset
6698 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6699 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6700 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6701
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6702 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6703 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6704 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6705 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6706 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6707 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6708 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6709 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6710 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6711 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6712 < In the |:autocmd|'s: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6713 :let b:gzflag = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6714 < And: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6715 :unlet b:gzflag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6716 < And define this function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6717 :function VarExists(var, val)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6718 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6719 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6720 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6721 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6722 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6723 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6724 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6725 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6726 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6727 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6728 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6729 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6730 including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6731 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6732 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6733 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6734 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6736 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6737 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6738 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6739 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6740 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6741 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6742 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6743 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6744 :set suffixesadd=.java
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6745 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6746 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6747 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6748 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6749 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6750 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6751 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6752 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6753 Careful: All text will be in memory:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6754 - Don't use this for big files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6755 - Recovery will be impossible!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6756 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6757 'swapfile' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6758 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6759 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6760 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6761 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6762
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6763 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6764 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6765
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6766 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6767 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6768 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6769 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6770 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6771 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6772 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6773 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6774 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6775 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6776 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6777 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6778 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6779 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6780
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6781 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6782 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6783 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6784 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6785 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6786 Possible values (comma separated list):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6787 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6788 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6789 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6790 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6791 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6792 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6793 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
825
6675076019ae updated for version 7.0d
vimboss
parents: 824
diff changeset
6794 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
6795 pages.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6796 split If included, split the current window before loading
3153
37ecb8ff4560 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3082
diff changeset
6797 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
37ecb8ff4560 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3082
diff changeset
6798 Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6799 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
6800 "split" when both are present.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6801
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6802 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6803 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6804 local to buffer
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6805 {not in Vi}
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6806 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6807 feature}
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6808 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6809 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6810 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6811 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6812 long line.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6813 Set to zero to remove the limit.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
6814
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6815 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6816 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6817 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6818 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6819 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6820 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6821 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6822 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6823 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6824 b:current_syntax variable does).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6825 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6826 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6827 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6828 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6829 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6830 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6831 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6832 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6833 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
6834 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6835 :set syntax=OFF
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6836 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6837 'filetype' option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6838 :set syntax=ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6839 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6840 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6841 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6842 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
6843 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6844
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6845 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6846 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6847 global
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6848 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6849 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6850 feature}
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6851 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6852 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6853 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6854
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6855 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
6856 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
6857 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
2572
ee53a39d5896 Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2570
diff changeset
6858 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6859
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6860 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6861 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6862 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6863 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6864
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6865 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6866 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6867
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
6868
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6869 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6870 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6871 global
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6872 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6873 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6874 feature}
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6875 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6876 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6877
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6878
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6879 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6880 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6881 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6882 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6883 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6884
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6885 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6886 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6888 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6889 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6890 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
6891 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6892 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6893 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6894 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6895 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6896 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6897 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6898 works when using Vim to edit the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6899 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6900 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6901 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6902 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6903 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6904 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6906 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6907 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6908 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6909 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6910 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6911 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6912 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6913 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6914 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6915 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6916 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6917
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6918 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6919 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6920 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6921 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6922
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6923 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6924 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6925 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6926 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6928 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6929 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6930 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6931 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6932 be found in the retry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6933
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
6934 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6935 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6936 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6937 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6938 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6939 5.x or higher (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6940 for this as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6941 to work.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6942
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6943 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6944 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6945 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6946 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6947 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6948 must be included in the tags file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6949 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6950 command-line completion and ":help").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6951 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6952
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6953 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6954 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6955 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6956 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6957
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6958 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6959 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6960 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6961 {not in Vi}
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
6962 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
6963 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6964 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6965 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6966
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6967 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6968 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6969 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6970 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6971 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6972 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6973 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6974 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6975 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6976 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6977 |tags-option|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6978 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
2522
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
6979 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
6980 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
6981 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
6982 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
6983 |+path_extra| feature}
515
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6984 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
6985 actually used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6986 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6987 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6988 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6989 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6990 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6991 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6992 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6993 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6994
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6995 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6996 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6997 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6998 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6999 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7000 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7001 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7002 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7003 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7004 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7005 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7006
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7007 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7008 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7009 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7010 on Amiga: "amiga"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7011 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7012 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7013 on MiNT: "vt52"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7014 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7015 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7016 on Unix: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7017 on VMS: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7018 on Win 32: "win32")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7019 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7020 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7021 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7022 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7023 :set term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7024 < See |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7025
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7026 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7027 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7028 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7029 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7030 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7031 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7032 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7033 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7034 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7035 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7036 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7037 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7038 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7039 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7040 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7041 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7042
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7043 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7044 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7045 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7046 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7047 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7048 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7049 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7050 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7051 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7052 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
7053 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
7054 'termencoding' should be "macroman".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7055 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7056 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7057 *E617*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7058 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7059 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7060 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7061 message is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7062 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7063 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7064 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7065 This is the normal value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7066 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7067 |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7068 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7069 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7070 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7071 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7072 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7073 :let &termencoding = &encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7074 :set encoding=utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7075 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7076
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7077 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7078 'terse' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7079 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7080 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7081 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7082 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7083 shortens a lot of messages}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7084
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7085 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7086 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7087 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7088 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7089 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7090 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7091 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7092 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7093 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7094 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7095
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7096 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7097 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7098 others: default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7099 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7100 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7101 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7102 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7103 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7104 "unix".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7106 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7107 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7108 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7109 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7110 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7111 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7112 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7113 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7114 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 836
diff changeset
7115 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7116 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7117
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7118 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7119 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7120 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7121 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7122 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7123 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7124 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7125 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7126 length is 510 bytes.
3496
d1e4abe8342c Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3493
diff changeset
7127 To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site:
d1e4abe8342c Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3493
diff changeset
7128 ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7129 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7130 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7131 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7132 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7133 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7134 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7135 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7136
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7137 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7138 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7139 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7140 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7141 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7142 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7144 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7145 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7146 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7147 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7148 'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7149 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7150 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7151 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7152 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7153
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7154 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7155 off off do not time out
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7156 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7157 off on time out on key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7159 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7160 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7161 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7162 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7163 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7164 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7165 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7166 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7167 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7168 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7169 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7170 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7171 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7172 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7173 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7174 reset the 'timeout' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7176 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7177
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7178 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7179 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7180 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7181 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7182 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7183 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7184 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7185 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7186 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7187 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7188 when part of a command has been typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7189 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7190 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7191 a non-negative number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7193 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7194 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7195 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7196
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7197 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7198 tell so. A useful setting would be >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7199 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7200 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7201 a tenth of a second).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7202
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7203 *'title'* *'notitle'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7204 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7205 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7206 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7207 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7208 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7209 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7210 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7211 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7212 Where:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7213 filename the name of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7214 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7215 + indicates the file was modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7216 = indicates the file is read-only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7217 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7218 (path) is the path of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7219 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7220 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7221 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7222 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7223 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7224 *X11*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7225 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7226 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7227 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7228 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7229 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7230 will not work (except in the GUI).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7231 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7232 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7233 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7234 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7235 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7236 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7237 exiting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7238
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7239 *'titlelen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7240 'titlelen' number (default 85)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7241 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7242 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7243 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7244 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7245 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7246 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7247 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7248 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7249 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7250 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7251 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7252 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7253 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7255 *'titleold'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7256 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7257 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7258 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7259 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7260 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7261 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7262 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7263 'titlestring' is not empty.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7264 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7265 security reasons.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7266 *'titlestring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7267 'titlestring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7268 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7269 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7270 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7271 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7272 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7273 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7274 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7275 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7276 non-empty 't_ts' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7277 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7278 be restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7279 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7280 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7281 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7282 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7283 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7284 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7285 of the available space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7286 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7287 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7288 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7289 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7290 separating space only when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7291 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7292 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7293 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7295 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7296 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7297 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7298 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7299 |+GUI_Photon|}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7300 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7301 possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7302 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7303 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7304 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7305 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7306 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7307 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7308 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7309
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7310 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7311 following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7312 :set tb=icons,text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7313 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7314 will show icons if both are requested.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7316 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7317 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7318 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7319 :set guioptions-=T
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7320 < Also see |gui-toolbar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7321
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7322 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7323 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7324 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7325 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7326 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7327 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7328 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7329 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7330 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7331 large Use large toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7332 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7333 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7334 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7336 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7337 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7339 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7340 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7341 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7342 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7343 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7344 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7345 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7346 the change to take effect, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7347 :set notbi term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7348 < See also |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7349 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7350 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7351 xterm entries...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7352
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7353 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7354 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7355 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7356 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7357 a DOS console)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7358 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7359 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7360 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7361 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7362 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7363 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7364 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7365 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7366 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7367
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7368 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7369 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7370 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7371 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7372 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7373 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7374 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
1213
8906c10ecbb0 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1152
diff changeset
7375 Currently these strings are valid:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7376 *xterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7377 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7378 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7379 "s" = button state
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7380 "c" = column plus 33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7381 "r" = row plus 33
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
7382 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec" for a
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
7383 solution.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7384 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7385 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7386 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
7387 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7388 work. See below for how Vim detects this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7389 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7390 *netterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7391 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7392 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7393 for the row and column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7394 *dec-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7395 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7396 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
7397 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
7398 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7399 *jsbterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7400 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7401 *pterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7402 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7403 *urxvt-mouse*
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7404 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7406 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7407 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7408 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7409 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7410 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7411 "xterm" (because the xterm and dec mouse codes conflict).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7412 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7413 set to a name that starts with "xterm", and 'ttymouse' is not "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7414 or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7415 "xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7416 handle xterm mouse codes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7417 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7418 95 or higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7419 feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7420 xterm version number. Otherwise "xterm2" must be set explicitly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7421 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" automatically, set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7422 t_RV to an empty string: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7423 :set t_RV=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7424 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7425 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7426 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7427 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7428 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7429 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7430 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7431 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7432
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7433 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7434 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7435 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7436 Alias for 'term', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7437
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7438 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7439 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7440 global
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7441 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7442 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7443 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
2220
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7444 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
2218
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7445 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7446 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7447 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7448 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7449 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7450 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7451 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7452 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7453 given, no further entry is used.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7454 See |undo-persistence|.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7455
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7456 *'undofile'* *'udf'*
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7457 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7458 local to buffer
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7459 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7460 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7461 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7462 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7463 file on buffer read.
2220
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7464 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7465 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
2394
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7466 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7467 before a reload to be saved for undo.
2220
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7468 WARNING: this is a very new feature. Use at your own risk!
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7469
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7470 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7471 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7472 Win32 and OS/2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7473 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7474 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7475 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7476 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7477 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7478 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7479 itself: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7480 set ul=0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7481 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7482 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2240
diff changeset
7483 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7484 Set to a negative number for no undo at all: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7485 set ul=-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7486 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2240
diff changeset
7487 Also see |clear-undo|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7488
2394
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7489 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7490 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7491 global
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7492 {not in Vi}
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7493 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7494 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7495 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7496 The save only happens when this options is negative or when the number
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7497 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7498 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7499
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7500 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7501
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7502 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7503 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7504
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7505 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7506 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7507 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7508 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7509 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7510 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7511 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7512 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7513 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7514 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7515 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7516 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7517 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7518 Also see |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7519 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7520 or "nowrite".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7522 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7523 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7524 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7525 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7526 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7527 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7528 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7529
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7530 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7531 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7532 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7533 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7534 verbose option}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7535 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7536 Currently, these messages are given:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7537 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7538 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7539 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7540 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7541 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7542 >= 12 Every executed function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7543 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7544 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7545 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7547 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7548 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7549
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7550 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7551 displayed.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7552
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7553 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7554 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7555 global
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7556 {not in Vi}
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7557 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7558 When the file exists messages are appended.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7559 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
2265
b7cb69ab616d Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
7560 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7561 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7562 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7563 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7564
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7565 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7566 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7567 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7568 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7569 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7570 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7571 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7572 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7573 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7574 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7575 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7576 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7577 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7578 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7579
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7580 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7581 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7582 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7583 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7584 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7585 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7586 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7587 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7588 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7589 cursor cursor position in file and in window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7590 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7591 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7592 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7593 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7594 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7595 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7596 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7597 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7598
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7599 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7600 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7601 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7603 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7604 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7605 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7606 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7607 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7608 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7609 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7610 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7611 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7612 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7613 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7614 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7615 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7616 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7617 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7618 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7619 the effect of their value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7620 CHAR VALUE ~
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7621 *viminfo-!*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7622 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7623 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7624 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
2607
2f57d93bdbf6 updated for version 7.3.030
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2587
diff changeset
7625 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
7626 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7627 *viminfo-quote*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7628 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7629 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7630 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7631 start of a comment!
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7632 *viminfo-%*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7633 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7634 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7635 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7636 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7637 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7638 to the viminfo file.
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7639 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7640 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7641 buffers are stored.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7642 *viminfo-'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7643 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7644 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7645 'viminfo' is non-empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7646 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7647 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7648 *viminfo-/*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7649 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7650 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7651 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7652 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7653 *viminfo-:*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7654 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7655 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7656 *viminfo-<*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7657 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7658 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7659 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7660 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7661 *viminfo-@*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7662 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7663 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7664 *viminfo-c*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7665 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7666 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7667 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7668 *viminfo-f*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7669 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7670 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7671 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7672 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7673 *viminfo-h*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7674 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7675 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7676 has been used since the last search command.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7677 *viminfo-n*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7678 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7679 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7680 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7681 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7682 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7683 *viminfo-r*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7684 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7685 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7686 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7687 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7688 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7689 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7690 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7691 characters.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7692 *viminfo-s*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7693 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7694 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7695 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7696 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7697
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7698 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7699 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7700 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7701 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7702 edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7703 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7704 remembered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7705 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7706 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7707 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7708 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7709 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7710 previous search and substitute patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7711 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7712 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7713
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7714 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7715 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7717 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7718 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7719
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7720 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7721 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7722 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7723 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7724 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7725 |+virtualedit| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7726 A comma separated list of these words:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7727 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7728 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7729 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7730 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7731
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7732 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
7733 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7734 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7735 editing a table.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7736 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7737 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7738 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7739 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7740 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7741 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7742 Using the |$| command will move to the last character in the line, not
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7743 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7744 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
7745 not get a warning for it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7746
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7747 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7748 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7749 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7750 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7751 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7752 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7753 use ":set vb t_vb=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7754 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7755 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7756 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7757 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7758 where 40 is the time in msec.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7759 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7760 Also see 'errorbells'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7761
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7762 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7763 'warn' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7764 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7765 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7766 has been changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7767
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7768 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7769 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7770 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7771 {not in Vi}
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
7772 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7773 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7774 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7775 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7776
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7777 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7778 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7779 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7780 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7781 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7782 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7783 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7784 char key mode ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7785 b <BS> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7786 s <Space> Normal and Visual
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7787 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7788 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7789 < <Left> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7790 > <Right> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7791 ~ "~" Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7792 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7793 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7794 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7795 :set ww=<,>,[,]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7796 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7797 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7798 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7799 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7800 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7801 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7802 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7803 cursor.
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7804 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7805 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
7806 "yl" etc. work normally.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7807 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7808 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7810 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7811 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7812 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7813 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7814 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7815 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7816 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7817 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7818 'wildcharm' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7819 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7820 :set wc=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7821 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7822 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7823
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7824 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7825 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7826 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7827 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7828 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7829 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7830 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7831 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7832 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7833 :set wcm=<C-Z>
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7834 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7835 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7836
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7837 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7838 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7839 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7840 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7841 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7842 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7843 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
1754
28d0c20ad8a0 updated for version 7.2-051
vimboss
parents: 1702
diff changeset
7844 patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names, and
28d0c20ad8a0 updated for version 7.2-051
vimboss
parents: 1702
diff changeset
7845 influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and |globpath()| unless
28d0c20ad8a0 updated for version 7.2-051
vimboss
parents: 1702
diff changeset
7846 a flag is passed to disable this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7847 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7848 Also see 'suffixes'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7849 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7850 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7851 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7852 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7853 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7854
2652
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7855
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
7856 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
2652
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7857 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7858 global
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7859 {not in Vi}
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7860 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7861 Has no effect on systems where file name case is generally ignored.
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7862 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7863 happens when there are special characters.
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7864
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
7865
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7866 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7867 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7868 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7869 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7870 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7871 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7872 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7873 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7874 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7875 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7876 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7877 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7878 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7879 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7880 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7881 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7882 as needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7883 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7884 for selecting a completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7885 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7886 meanings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7888 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7889 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7890 subdirectory or submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7891 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7892 dot: move into a submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7893 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7894 parent directory or parent menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7895
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7896 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7897
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7898 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7899 of selecting a different match, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7900 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7901 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7902 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7903 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7904 |hl-WildMenu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7906 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7907 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7908 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7909 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7910 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7911 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
7912 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7913 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7914 The second part for the second use, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7915 These are the possible values for each part:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7916 "" Complete only the first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7917 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7918 the original string is used and then the first match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7919 again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7920 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7921 result in a longer string, use the next part.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7922 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7923 enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7924 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7925 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7926 complete first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7927 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7928 complete till longest common string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7929 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7930
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7931 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7932 :set wildmode=full
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7933 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7934 :set wildmode=longest,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7935 < Complete longest common string, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7936 :set wildmode=list:full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7937 < List all matches and complete each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7938 :set wildmode=list,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7939 < List all matches without completing, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7940 :set wildmode=longest,list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7941 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7942 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7943
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7944 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7945 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7946 global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7947 {not in Vi}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7948 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7949 feature}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7950 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7951 Currently only one word is allowed:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7952 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
7953 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7954 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7955 d #define
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7956 f function
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7957 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
7958
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7959 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7960 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7961 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7962 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7963 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7964 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7965 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7966 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7967 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7968 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7969 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7970 done with the |:simalt| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7971 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7972 combinations cannot be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7973 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7974 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7975 keys can be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7976 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7977 key is never used for the menu.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7978 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7979 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7980
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7981 *'window'* *'wi'*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7982 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7983 global
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7984 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7985 use 'lines' for that.
179
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7986 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7987 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
7988 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7989 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7990 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7991 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7992 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7993 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
7994
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7995 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7996 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7997 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7998 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7999 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8000 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8001 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8002 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8003 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8004 cost of the height of other windows.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8005 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8006 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8007 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8008 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8009 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8010 using the |VimEnter| event: >
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8011 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8012 < Minimum value is 1.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8013 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8014 height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8015 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8016 the minimal height for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8017
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8018 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8019 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8020 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8021 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8022 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8023 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8024 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8025 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8026 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8027 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8028
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8029 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8030 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8031 local to window
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8032 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8033 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8034 feature}
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8035 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8036 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8037 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8038
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8039 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8040 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8041 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8042 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8043 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8044 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8045 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8046 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8047 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8048 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8049 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8050 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8051 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8052 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8053 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8055 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8056 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8057 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8058 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8059 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8060 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8061 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8062 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8063 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8064 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8065 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8066 to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8067 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8068 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8069 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8070 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8071
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8072 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8073 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8074 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8075 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8076 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8077 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8078 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8079 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8080 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8081 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8082 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8083 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8084 width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8085 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8086 the minimal width for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8087
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8088 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8089 'wrap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8090 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8091 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8092 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8093 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8094 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8095 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8096 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8097 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8098 horizontally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8099 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8100 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8101 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8102 :set sidescroll=5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8103 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8104 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
8105 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
8106 on.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8108 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8109 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8110 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8111 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8112 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8113 and inserting continues on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8114 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8115 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8116 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8117 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8118 and less usefully}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8119
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8120 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8121 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8122 global
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
8123 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
8124 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8126 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8127 'write' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8128 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8129 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8130 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8131 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8132 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8133 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8134 writing a temporary file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8136 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8137 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8138 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8139 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8141 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8142 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8143 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8144 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8145 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8146 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8147 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
3513
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8148 also on.
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8149 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8150 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8151 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8152 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8153 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8154 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8155 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8156 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8157 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8159 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8160 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8161 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8162 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8163 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8164 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8165 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8166
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8167 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: